blob: 60c716353a90ef22524d6f492db6e563a07b104f [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000282 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000283 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000284 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
285 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000286
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000287 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
288}
289
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000290/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
291/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
292/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
293/// completely illegal.
294bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000297 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000298 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
299 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
300 << Expr->getType() << CT))
301 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000302
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000303 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000305 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000308
309 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000310}
311
312
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000313/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
314/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000315/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000316/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
317/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
318/// GCC.
319QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
320 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000321 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000323
324 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000325
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000326 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000327 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000328 QualType lhs =
329 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000330 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000331 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000332
333 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
334 if (lhs == rhs)
335 return lhs;
336
337 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
338 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
339 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
340 return lhs;
341
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000342 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000343 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000344 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
345 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000346 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000347 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
348 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
349
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000350 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000351 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000352 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
353 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000354 return destType;
355}
356
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000357//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
358// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
359//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
360
361
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000362/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000363/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
364/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
365/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
366/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000367///
368Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000369Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000370 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
371
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000372 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000373 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000374 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000375
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000376 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000377 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
378 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000379
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000380 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000381 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000382 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000383
384 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000385 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000386 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000387
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
389 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
390 // strings.
391 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000392 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000393 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000394
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000395 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000396 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000397 Literal.GetStringLength(),
398 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
399 &StringTokLocs[0],
400 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401}
402
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000403/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
404/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
405/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
406/// for values inside the block or for globals).
407///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000408/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000409/// up-to-date.
410///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000411static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000412 ValueDecl *VD) {
413 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
414 // we wanted to.
415 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
416 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000417
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
419 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
420 return false;
421
422 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
423 // snapshot it.
424 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
425 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000426 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
427 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000428
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000429 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
430 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
431
432 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
433 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
434 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
435 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000436 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
437 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000438
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000439 if (!NextBlock)
440 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000441
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
443 // having a reference outside it.
444 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
445 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000446
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000447 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
448 // a snapshot as well.
449 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
450 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000451
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000452 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000453}
454
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000455
456
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000457/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000458Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000459Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000460 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000461 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
462 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000464 << D->getDeclName();
465 return ExprError();
466 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000468 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000469 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
470 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
471 // visible.
472 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000473 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
474 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000475 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000476 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000477 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000478 << D->getIdentifier();
479 return ExprError();
480 }
481 }
482 }
483 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000485 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000487 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
488 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
489 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000490 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000491}
492
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000493/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
494/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
495/// is Record.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000496static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
497 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000498 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000499 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000500
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000501 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
502 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
503 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000504 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000506 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000507 D != DEnd; ++D) {
508 if (*D == Record) {
509 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
510 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
511 ++D;
512 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor6e6ad602009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000513 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 return *D;
515 }
516 }
517
518 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
519 return 0;
520}
521
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000522/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
523/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
524/// actual member.
525///
526/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
527/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
528/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
529/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
530/// we found.
531///
532/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
533/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
534/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
535VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
536 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000537 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
538 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
539 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
540
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000542 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
543 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
544 do {
545 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000546 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000548 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000549 else {
550 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
551 break;
552 }
553 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000554 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000555 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556
557 return BaseObject;
558}
559
560Sema::OwningExprResult
561Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
562 FieldDecl *Field,
563 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
564 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
565 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000566 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567 AnonFields);
568
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000569 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
570 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
571 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
572 // found via name lookup.
573 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000574 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 if (BaseObject) {
576 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
577 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000578 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000579 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000580 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000581 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000582 BaseQuals
583 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
585 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
586 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
587 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
588 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000589 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
592 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000593 BaseQuals
594 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 } else {
596 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
597 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
598 // program our base object expression is "this".
599 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
600 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000601 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 = Context.getTagDeclType(
603 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
604 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000605 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000606 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
607 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
608 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000609 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000610 MD->getThisType(Context),
611 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000612 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
613 }
614 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000615 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
616 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000618 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 }
620
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000621 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000622 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
623 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000624 }
625
626 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
627 // anonymous struct/union.
628 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000629 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000630 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
631 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
632 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
633 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000634 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
635 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
636
637 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
638 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
639 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
640 ResultQuals.removeConst();
641
642 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
643 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
644
645 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
646 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
647
648 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
649 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
650 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
651
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000652 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000653 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000654 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000655 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
656 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000657 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000658 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000659 }
660
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000661 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000662}
663
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000664/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
665/// possibly a list of template arguments.
666///
667/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
668/// DecomposeTemplateName.
669///
670/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
671/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
672/// some way.
673static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
674 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
675 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
676 DeclarationName &Name,
677 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
678 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
679 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
680 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
681 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
682
683 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
684 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
685 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
686 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
687 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
688
689 TemplateName TName =
690 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
691
692 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
693 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
694 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
695 } else {
696 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
697 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
698 TemplateArgs = 0;
699 }
700}
701
702/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
703///
704/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
705/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
706/// found template arguments.
707static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
708 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
709 TemplateName TName =
710 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
711
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000712 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
713 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000714 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
715 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
716 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000717 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000718
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000719 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000720}
721
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000722/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
723/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
724/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000725static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000726 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
727 return false;
728
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000729 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
730 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
731 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
732 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
733 if (!BaseRT) return false;
734
735 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000736 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000737 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
738 return false;
739 }
740
741 return true;
742}
743
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000744/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
745/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
746static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000747 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000748
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000749 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
750 if (!DC) return true;
751
752 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
753 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
754
755 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
756 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
757
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 return false;
759}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000760
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000761/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
762/// the prospective base classes.
763static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
764 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
765 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000766 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000767 return false;
768
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000769 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000770 if (!RD) return false;
771 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
772
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000773 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
774 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
775 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
776 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
777 if (!BaseRT) return false;
778
779 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
781 return false;
782 }
783
784 return true;
785}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000786
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787enum IMAKind {
788 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
789 IMA_Static,
790
791 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
792 IMA_Mixed,
793
794 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
795 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
797
798 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
799 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
800 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
801
802 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
803 IMA_Instance,
804
805 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
806 IMA_Unresolved,
807
808 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
809 /// context is not an instance method.
810 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
811
812 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
813 /// non-class context.
814 IMA_AnonymousMember,
815
816 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
817 /// context is not an instance method.
818 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
819
820 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
821 /// class.
822 IMA_Error_Unrelated
823};
824
825/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
826/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
827/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
828/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
829/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
830/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
831static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
832 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000833 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000834
835 bool isStaticContext =
836 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext) ||
837 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->isStatic());
838
839 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
840 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
841
842 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
843 bool hasNonInstance = false;
844 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
845 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000846 NamedDecl *D = *I;
847 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000848 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
849
850 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
851 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
852 // that's a special case.
853 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
854 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
855 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
856 }
857 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
858 }
859 else
860 hasNonInstance = true;
861 }
862
863 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
864 // member reference.
865 if (Classes.empty())
866 return IMA_Static;
867
868 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
869 // an implicit member reference.
870 if (isStaticContext)
871 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
872
873 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
874 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
875 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
876 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
877 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getParent(),
878 Classes))
879 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
880
881 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
882}
883
884/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
885static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
886 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
887 const LookupResult &R) {
888 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
889 SourceRange Range(Loc);
890 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
891
892 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
893 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
894 if (MD->isStatic()) {
895 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
896 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
897 << Range << R.getLookupName();
898 return;
899 }
900 }
901
902 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
903 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
904 return;
905 }
906
907 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000908}
909
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000910/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
911///
912/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000913bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000914 LookupResult &R) {
915 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
916
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000917 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000918 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000919 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
920 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000921 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000923 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
924 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000926 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
927 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
928 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
929 // dependent name.
930 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
931 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000932 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
933 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
934
935 if (!R.empty()) {
936 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
937 R.suppressDiagnostics();
938
939 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
940 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
941 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
942 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
943
944 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
945 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
946 // Actually quite difficult!
947 if (isInstance)
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000949 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000950 else
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
952
953 // Do we really want to note all of these?
954 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
955 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
956
957 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
958 return false;
959 }
960 }
961 }
962
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000963 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 DeclarationName Corrected;
965 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS))) {
966 if (!R.empty()) {
967 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
968 if (SS.isEmpty())
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
970 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
971 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange()
976 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
977 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
978 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
979 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
980 << ND->getDeclName();
981
982 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
983 return false;
984 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000985
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
987 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
988 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
989 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
990 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
991 // to recover well anyway.
992 if (SS.isEmpty())
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
994 else
995 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
996 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
997 << SS.getRange();
998
999 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001003 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001004 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001005 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001006 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001007 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001008 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001009 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1010 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001011 return true;
1012 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001013 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001014 }
1015
1016 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1017 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1018 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1019 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1020 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1021 << SS.getRange();
1022 return true;
1023 }
1024
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001025 // Give up, we can't recover.
1026 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1027 return true;
1028}
1029
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001030Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001031 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001032 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1033 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1034 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1035 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1036 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1037
1038 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001039 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001040
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001041 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001042
1043 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1044 DeclarationName Name;
1045 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1046 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001047 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1048 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001049
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001050 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001051
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001052 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1053 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001054 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1055 // (note: handled after lookup)
1056 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1057 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1058 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001059 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1060 // names a dependent type.
1061 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1062 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001063 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1064 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1065 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001067 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001068 TemplateArgs);
1069 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001070
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001071 // Perform the required lookup.
1072 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1073 if (TemplateArgs) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001074 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001075 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00001076
1077 // Re-derive the naming class.
1078 if (SS.isSet()) {
1079 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
1080 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
1081 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
1082 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
1083 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
1084 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001085 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001086 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1087 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001088
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1090 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001091 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1092 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 if (E.isInvalid())
1094 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001095
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1097 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001098 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001099 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001100
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001101 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1102 return ExprError();
1103
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001104 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1105 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001106 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001107
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001108 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001109 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001110 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1111 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1112 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1113 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1114 }
1115
1116 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1117 // call, diagnose the problem.
1118 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001119 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001120 return ExprError();
1121
1122 assert(!R.empty() &&
1123 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001124
1125 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1126 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001127 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001128 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1129 R.clear();
1130 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1131 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1132 return move(E);
1133 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001134 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001135 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1138 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1139
1140 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001141 // Warn about constructs like:
1142 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1143 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1145 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001146 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001147 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001148 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001149 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001150 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001151 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1152 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001153 break;
1154 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001155
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001156 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1157 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001158 }
1159 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001160 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001161 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1162 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1163 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1164 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1165 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1166 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001167 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001168 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001169
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001170 QualType T = Func->getType();
1171 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001172 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001173 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001174 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001175 }
1176 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001177
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001178 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1179 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1180 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1181 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1182 // class member access expression.
1183 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1184 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001185 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001186 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001187 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1188 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001189 }
1190
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001191 if (TemplateArgs)
1192 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001193
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1195}
1196
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001197/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1198Sema::OwningExprResult
1199Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1200 LookupResult &R,
1201 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1202 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1203 case IMA_Instance:
1204 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1205
1206 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1207 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1208 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1209 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1210
1211 case IMA_Mixed:
1212 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1213 case IMA_Unresolved:
1214 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1215
1216 case IMA_Static:
1217 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1218 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1219 if (TemplateArgs)
1220 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1221 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1222
1223 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1224 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1225 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1226 return ExprError();
1227 }
1228
1229 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1230 return ExprError();
1231}
1232
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001233/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1234/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1235/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1236/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001237Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001238Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001239 DeclarationName Name,
1240 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1241 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001242 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001243 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1244
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001245 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001246 return ExprError();
1247
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001248 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1249 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1250
1251 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1252 return ExprError();
1253
1254 if (R.empty()) {
1255 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1256 return ExprError();
1257 }
1258
1259 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1260}
1261
1262/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1263/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1264/// additional lookup.
1265///
1266/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1267/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1268///
1269/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1270Sema::OwningExprResult
1271Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001272 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001274 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001275
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001276 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1277 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1278 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1279 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1280 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1281
1282 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1283 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1284 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001285 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001286
1287 bool LookForIvars;
1288 if (Lookup.empty())
1289 LookForIvars = true;
1290 else if (IsClassMethod)
1291 LookForIvars = false;
1292 else
1293 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1294 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001295 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001296 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001297 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001298 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1299 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1300 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1301 if (IsClassMethod)
1302 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1303 << IV->getDeclName());
1304
1305 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1306 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1307 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1308 return ExprError();
1309
1310 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1311 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1312 return ExprError();
1313
1314 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1315 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1316 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1317 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1318
1319 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1320 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1321 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1322 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001323 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1325 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1326 SelfName, false, false);
1327 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1328 return Owned(new (Context)
1329 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1330 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1331 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001332 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001333 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001334 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001335 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1336 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1337 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1338 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1339 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1340 }
1341 }
1342
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001343 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1344 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1345 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1346 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1347 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1348 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1349 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1350 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1351 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1352 }
1353 }
1354 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001355 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1356 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001357}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001358
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001359/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1360///
1361/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1362///
1363/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1364/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1365/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1366/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1367///
1368/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1369/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1370/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1371/// the class declaring the member.
1372///
1373/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1374/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1375/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001376bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001377Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1378 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001379 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001380 NamedDecl *Member) {
1381 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1382 if (!RD)
1383 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001384
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001385 QualType DestRecordType;
1386 QualType DestType;
1387 QualType FromRecordType;
1388 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1389 bool PointerConversions = false;
1390 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1391 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001392
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001393 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1394 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1395 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1396 PointerConversions = true;
1397 } else {
1398 DestType = DestRecordType;
1399 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001400 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001401 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1402 if (Method->isStatic())
1403 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001404
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001405 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1406 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001407
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001408 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1409 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1410 PointerConversions = true;
1411 } else {
1412 FromRecordType = FromType;
1413 DestType = DestRecordType;
1414 }
1415 } else {
1416 // No conversion necessary.
1417 return false;
1418 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001419
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001420 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1421 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001422
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001423 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1424 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1425 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001426
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001427 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1428 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1429
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001430 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001431 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001432 // class name.
1433 //
1434 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1435 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1436 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1437 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1438 //
1439 // class Base { public: int x; };
1440 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1441 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1442 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1443 //
1444 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1445 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1446 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1447 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001448 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001449 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1450 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1451 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1452
1453 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1454
1455 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1456 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1457 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1458 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001459 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001461 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001462 return true;
1463
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001464 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001465 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001466 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001467 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001468
1469 FromType = QType;
1470 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1471
1472 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1473 // we're done.
1474 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1475 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001476 }
1477 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001478
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001479 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001480
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001481 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1482 // down to the using declaration's type.
1483 //
1484 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1485 // class ever has member declarations.
1486 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1487 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1488 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1489 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1490
1491 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1492 // conversion is non-trivial.
1493 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1494 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001495 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001496 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001497 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001498 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001499
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001500 QualType UType = URecordType;
1501 if (PointerConversions)
1502 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001503 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001504 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001505 FromType = UType;
1506 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1507 }
1508
1509 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1510 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1511 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001513
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001514 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1515 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1516 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001517 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001518 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001519
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001520 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001521 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001522 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001523}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001524
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001525/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001526static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001527 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001528 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1529 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001530 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1531 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1532 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001533 if (SS.isSet()) {
1534 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1535 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001536 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001537
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001538 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001539 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001540}
1541
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001542/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1543/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1544/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1545/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001546Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001547Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1548 LookupResult &R,
1549 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1550 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001551 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1552
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001553 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001554
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001555 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1556 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001557 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001558 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001559 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001560 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001561 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001562
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001563 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1564 // 'this' expression now.
1565 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)->getThisType(Context);
1566 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1567 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001568 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1569 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1570 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1571 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001572 }
1573
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001574 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1575 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1576 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001577 SS,
1578 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1579 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001580}
1581
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001582bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001583 const LookupResult &R,
1584 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001585 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1586 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1587 return false;
1588
1589 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001590 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001591 return false;
1592
1593 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001594 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001595 return false;
1596
1597 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1598 // normal lookup:
1599 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1600 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1601
1602 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1603 // -- a declaration of a class member
1604 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1605 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001606 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001607 return false;
1608
1609 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1610 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1611 // using-declaration
1612 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1613 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1614 // turn off ADL anyway).
1615 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1616 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1617 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1618 return false;
1619
1620 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1621 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1622 // template
1623 // And also for builtin functions.
1624 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1625 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1626
1627 // But also builtin functions.
1628 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1629 return false;
1630 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1631 return false;
1632 }
1633
1634 return true;
1635}
1636
1637
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001638/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1639/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1640/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1641/// will in fact be used.
1642static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1643 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1644 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1645 return true;
1646 }
1647
1648 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1649 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1650 return true;
1651 }
1652
1653 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1654 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1655 return true;
1656 }
1657
1658 return false;
1659}
1660
1661Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001662Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001663 LookupResult &R,
1664 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001665 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1666 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001667 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001668 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001669
1670 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1671 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1672 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001673 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1674 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001675 return ExprError();
1676
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001677 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1678 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1679 // we've picked a target.
1680 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1681
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001682 bool Dependent
1683 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001685 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001686 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1687 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001688 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1689 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001690 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001691
1692 return Owned(ULE);
1693}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001694
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001695
1696/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1697Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001698Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001699 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1700 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001701 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1702 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001703
1704 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1705 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001706
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001707 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1708 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1709 // a template argument list.
1710 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1711 << Template << SS.getRange();
1712 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1713 return ExprError();
1714 }
1715
1716 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1717 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1718 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001719 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001720 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001721 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001722 return ExprError();
1723 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001724
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001725 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1726 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1727 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1728 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001729 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001730 return ExprError();
1731
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001732 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1733 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001734 return ExprError();
1735
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001736 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1737 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1738 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1739 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001740 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001741 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1742 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1743 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001744 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001745 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001746 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1747 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1748 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1749 return ExprError();
1750 }
1751
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001752 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001753 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1754 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1755 return ExprError();
1756 }
1757
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001758 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001759 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001760 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001761 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001762 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001763 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1764 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001765 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001766
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001767 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001768 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001769 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001770 }
1771 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1772 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001773
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001774 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001775}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001776
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1778 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001779 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001780
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001781 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001782 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001783 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1784 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1785 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001786 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001787
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001788 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1789 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001790
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001791 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1792 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001793 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001794 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001795 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001796
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001797 QualType ResTy;
1798 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1799 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1800 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001801 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001802
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001803 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001804 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001805 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1806 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001807 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001808}
1809
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001810Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001811 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001812 bool Invalid = false;
1813 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1814 if (Invalid)
1815 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001816
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001817 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1818 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001819 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001820 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001821
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001822 QualType Ty;
1823 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1824 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1825 else if (Literal.isWide())
1826 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001827 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1828 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001829 else
1830 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001831
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001832 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1833 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001834 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001835}
1836
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001837Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1838 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001839 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1840 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001841 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001842 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001843 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001844 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001845 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001846
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001847 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001848 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1849 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001850 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001851
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001852 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001853 bool Invalid = false;
1854 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1855 if (Invalid)
1856 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001857
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001858 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001859 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001860 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001861 return ExprError();
1862
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001863 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001864
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001865 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001866 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001867 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001868 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001869 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001870 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001871 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001872 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001873
1874 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1875
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001876 using llvm::APFloat;
1877 APFloat Val(Format);
1878
1879 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001880
1881 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1882 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1883 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1884 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001885 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001886 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001887 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001888 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001889 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1890 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001891 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001892 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1893 }
1894
1895 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1896 << Ty
1897 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1898 }
1899
1900 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001901 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001902
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001903 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001904 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001905 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001906 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001907
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001908 // long long is a C99 feature.
1909 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001910 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001911 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1912
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001913 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001914 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001915
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001916 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1917 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1918 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001919 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1920 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001921 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001922 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001923 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1924 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001925
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001926 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1927 // be an unsigned int.
1928 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1929
1930 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001931 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001932 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1933 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001934 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001936 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1937 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1938 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1939 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001940 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001941 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001942 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001943 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001944 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001945 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001947 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001948 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001949 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001950
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001951 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1952 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1953 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1954 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001955 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001956 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001957 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001958 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001959 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001960 }
1961
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001962 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001963 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001964 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001966 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1967 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1968 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1969 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001970 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001971 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001972 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001973 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001974 }
1975 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001977 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1978 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001979 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001980 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001981 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001982 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001983 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001984
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001985 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1986 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001987 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001988 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001989 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001990
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001991 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1992 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001993 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001994 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001995
1996 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001997}
1998
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2000 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002001 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002002 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002003 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002004}
2005
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002006/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002007/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002008bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002009 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2010 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2011 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002012 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2013 return false;
2014
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002015 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2016 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2017 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2018 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2019 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2020 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2021
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002022 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002023 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002024 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002025 if (isSizeof)
2026 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2027 return false;
2028 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002030 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002031 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002032 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2033 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002034 return false;
2035 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002036
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002037 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002038 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2039 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002040 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002041
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002042 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002043 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002044 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002045 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2046 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002047 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002048
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002049 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002050}
2051
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002052bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2053 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2054 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002055
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002056 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002057 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2058 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002059
2060 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2061 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2062 return false;
2063
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002064 if (E->getBitField()) {
2065 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2066 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002067 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002068
2069 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2070 // bit-field.
2071 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002072 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002073 return false;
2074
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002075 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2076}
2077
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002078/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002079Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002080Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002081 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002082 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002083 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002084 return ExprError();
2085
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002086 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002087
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002088 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2089 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2090 return ExprError();
2091
2092 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002093 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002094 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2095 R.getEnd()));
2096}
2097
2098/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2099/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002100Action::OwningExprResult
2101Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002102 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2103 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2104 bool isInvalid = false;
2105 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2106 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2107 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2108 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002109 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002110 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2111 isInvalid = true;
2112 } else {
2113 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2114 }
2115
2116 if (isInvalid)
2117 return ExprError();
2118
2119 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2120 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2121 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2122 R.getEnd()));
2123}
2124
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002125/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2126/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2127/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002128Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002129Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2130 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002131 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002132 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002133
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002134 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002135 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2136 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2137 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002138 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002139
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002140 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2141 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2142 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2143
2144 if (Result.isInvalid())
2145 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2146
2147 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002148}
2149
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002150QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002151 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2152 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002154 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002155 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002156 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002157
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002158 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2159 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2160 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002161
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002162 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002163 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2164 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002165 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002166}
2167
2168
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002169
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002170Action::OwningExprResult
2171Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2172 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002173 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2174 switch (Kind) {
2175 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2176 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2177 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2178 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002179
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002180 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002181}
2182
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002183Action::OwningExprResult
2184Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2185 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002186 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2187 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2188
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002189 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2190 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002191
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002192 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002193 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2194 Base.release();
2195 Idx.release();
2196 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2197 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2198 }
2199
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002200 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002201 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002202 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2203 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2204 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002205 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002206 }
2207
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002208 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2209}
2210
2211
2212Action::OwningExprResult
2213Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2214 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2215 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2216 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2217
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002218 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002219 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2220 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2221 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002222
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002224
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002225 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002226 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002227 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002228 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002229 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2230 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002231 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2232 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2233 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2234 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002235 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002236 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2237 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002238 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002239 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002240 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002241 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2242 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002243 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002244 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002245 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002246 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2247 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2248 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002249 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002250 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002251 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2252 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2253 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2254 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002255 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002256 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002257 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002258
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002259 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2260 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002261 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2262 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002263 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002264 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2265 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2266 // force the promotion here.
2267 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2268 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002269 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2270 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002271 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2272
2273 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2274 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002275 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002276 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2277 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2278 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2279 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002280 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2281 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002282 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2283
2284 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2285 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002286 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002287 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002288 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2289 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002290 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002291 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002292 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2293 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002294 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2295 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002296
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002297 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002298 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2299 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002300 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2301
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002302 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2304 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002305 // incomplete types are not object types.
2306 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2307 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2308 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2309 return ExprError();
2310 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002312 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002313 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002314 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2315 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002316 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002317
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002318 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002319 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002320 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2321 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2322 return ExprError();
2323 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002324
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002325 Base.release();
2326 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002327 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002328 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002329}
2330
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002331QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002332CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002333 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002334 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002335 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2336 // see FIXME there.
2337 //
2338 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2339 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002340 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002341
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002342 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002343 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002345 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002346 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2347 // to be selected.
2348 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002349
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002350 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2351 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002352 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002353
2354 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2355 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002357 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2358 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002359 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002360 do
2361 compStr++;
2362 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002363 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002364 do
2365 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002366 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002367 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002369 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002370 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2371 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002372 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2373 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002374 return QualType();
2375 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002376
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002377 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2378 // operates on.
2379 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002380 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002381
2382 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002383 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384
2385 while (*compStr) {
2386 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2387 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2388 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2389 return QualType();
2390 }
2391 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002392 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002393
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002394 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002395 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002396 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002397 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002398 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002399 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002400 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002401 if (HexSwizzle)
2402 CompSize--;
2403
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002404 if (CompSize == 1)
2405 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002406
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002407 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002408 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002409 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2410 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2411 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2412 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002413 }
2414 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002415}
2416
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002417static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002418 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002419 const Selector &Sel,
2420 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002422 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002423 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002424 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002425 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002426
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002427 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2428 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002429 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002430 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002431 return D;
2432 }
2433 return 0;
2434}
2435
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002436static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002437 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002438 const Selector &Sel,
2439 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002440 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2441 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002442 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002443 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002444 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002445 GDecl = PD;
2446 break;
2447 }
2448 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002449 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002450 GDecl = OMD;
2451 break;
2452 }
2453 }
2454 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002455 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002456 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2457 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002458 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002459 if (GDecl)
2460 return GDecl;
2461 }
2462 }
2463 return GDecl;
2464}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002465
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002466Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002467Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2468 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002469 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2470 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2471 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2472 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2473 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2474
2475 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2476 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2477 //
2478 // T* t;
2479 // t.f;
2480 //
2481 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2482 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2483 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2484 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002485 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002486 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2487 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002488 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002489 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002490 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002491 return ExprError();
2492 }
2493 }
2494
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002495 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002496 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002497
2498 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2499 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002500 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002501 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2502 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2503 SS.getRange(),
2504 FirstQualifierInScope,
2505 Name, NameLoc,
2506 TemplateArgs));
2507}
2508
2509/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2510/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2511/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2512static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2513 Expr *BaseExpr,
2514 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002515 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002516 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002517 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2518 // diagnostics.
2519 if (!BaseExpr)
2520 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002521
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002522 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2523 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002524}
2525
2526// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2527// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2528// type. The restriction here is:
2529//
2530// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2531// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2532// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2533//
2534// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2535// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2536// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2537// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2538bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2539 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002540 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002541 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2543 if (!BaseRT) {
2544 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2545 // dependent.
2546 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2547 return false;
2548 }
2549 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002550
2551 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002552 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2553 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002554 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002555 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002556
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2558 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2559 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2560 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2561
2562 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2563 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2564
2565 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2566 return false;
2567 }
2568
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002569 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002570 return true;
2571}
2572
2573static bool
2574LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2575 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002576 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002577 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2578 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002579 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002580 << BaseRange))
2581 return true;
2582
2583 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2584 if (SS.isSet()) {
2585 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2586 // nested-name-specifier.
2587 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2588
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002589 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002590 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2591 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2592 return true;
2593 }
2594
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002595 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002596
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002597 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2598 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2599 << DC << SS.getRange();
2600 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002601 }
2602 }
2603
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002604 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2605 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002607 if (!R.empty())
2608 return false;
2609
2610 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2611 // for typos.
2612 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002613 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002614 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002615 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2616 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2617 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002618 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2619 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002620 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2621 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2622 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002623 return false;
2624 } else {
2625 R.clear();
2626 }
2627
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002628 return false;
2629}
2630
2631Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002632Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002634 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002635 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2636 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2637 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2638 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2639
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002640 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2641 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002642 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002643 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2644 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2645 Name, NameLoc,
2646 TemplateArgs);
2647
2648 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002649
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002650 // Implicit member accesses.
2651 if (!Base) {
2652 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2653 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2654 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2655 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2656 OpLoc, SS))
2657 return ExprError();
2658
2659 // Explicit member accesses.
2660 } else {
2661 OwningExprResult Result =
2662 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002663 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002664
2665 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2666 Owned(Base);
2667 return ExprError();
2668 }
2669
2670 if (Result.get())
2671 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002672
2673 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2674 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002675 }
2676
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002677 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002678 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2679 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002680}
2681
2682Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002683Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2684 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2685 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002686 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002688 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2689 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002690 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002691 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002692 if (IsArrow) {
2693 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2694 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2695 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002696 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697
2698 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2699 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2700 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2701 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2702
2703 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002704 return ExprError();
2705
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706 if (R.empty()) {
2707 // Rederive where we looked up.
2708 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2709 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2710 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002711
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002712 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002713 << MemberName << DC
2714 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002715 return ExprError();
2716 }
2717
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002718 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2719 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2720 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2721 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2722 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2723 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2724 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2725 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2726 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2727 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002728 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002729 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002730 return ExprError();
2731
2732 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2733 // result.
2734 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002735 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002736 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002737 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002738 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002739
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002740 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2741 // pick a member.
2742 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2743
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002744 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2745 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2746 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002747 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2748 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2750 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2751 TemplateArgs);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002752 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002753
2754 return Owned(MemExpr);
2755 }
2756
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002757 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002758 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002759 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2760
2761 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2762
2763 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2764 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2765 // error cases.
2766 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2767 return ExprError();
2768
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002769 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2770 if (!BaseExpr) {
2771 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002772 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002773 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2774
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002775 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2776 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2777 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2778 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 }
2780
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002781 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2782 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2783 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2784 // explicitly qualified.
2785 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2786 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2787 }
2788
2789 // Check the use of this member.
2790 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2791 Owned(BaseExpr);
2792 return ExprError();
2793 }
2794
2795 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2796 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2797 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002798 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2799 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002800 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2801 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2802
2803 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2804 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2805 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2806 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2807 else {
2808 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2809 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2810 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2811
2812 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2813 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2814
2815 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2816 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2817 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2818 }
2819
2820 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002821 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 return ExprError();
2823 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002824 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825 }
2826
2827 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2828 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2829 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002830 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2832 }
2833
2834 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2835 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2836 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002837 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002838 MemberFn->getType()));
2839 }
2840
2841 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2842 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2843 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002844 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002845 }
2846
2847 Owned(BaseExpr);
2848
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002849 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002850 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002851 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2852 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2853 else
2854 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2855 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002856
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002857 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2858 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002859 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002860 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002861}
2862
2863/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2864/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2865/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2866/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2867/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2868/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2869/// an ordinary member expression.
2870///
2871/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2872/// fixed for ObjC++.
2873Sema::OwningExprResult
2874Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002875 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002876 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002878 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002879
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002880 // Perform default conversions.
2881 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002882
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002883 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002884 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2885
2886 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2887 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002888
2889 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002890 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002891 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2892 // call, and continue on.
2893 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2894 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2895 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2896 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2897 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002898 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2899 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002900 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2901 ->isRecordType()))) {
2902 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2903 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2904 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002905 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002906
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002907 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002908 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002909 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2910 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002911 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002912
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002913 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2914 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2915 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2916 }
2917 }
2918 }
2919
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002920 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2921 // use that.
2922 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002923 if (IsArrow) {
2924 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2925 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2926 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002927 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002928 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002929 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2930 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002931 }
2932 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002933 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2934 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2935 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2936 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002937 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002938 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002939 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002941 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2942 // use that.
2943 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2944 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2945 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2946 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2947 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2948 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2949 }
2950 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002951
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002952 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002953
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002954 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002956 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2957 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2958 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2959 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2960 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2961 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2962 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2963 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2964 // Check the use of this method.
2965 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2966 return ExprError();
2967 }
2968 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2969 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2970 Selector SetterSel =
2971 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2972 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2973 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2974 if (!Setter) {
2975 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2976 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002977 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002978 }
2979 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2980 if (!Setter)
2981 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002982
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002983 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2984 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002985
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002986 if (Getter || Setter) {
2987 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002988
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002989 if (Getter)
2990 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2991 else
2992 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2993 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2994 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002995 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002996 PType,
2997 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2998 }
2999 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3000 << MemberName << BaseType);
3001 }
3002 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003003
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003004 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3005 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3006 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003007 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003008 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003009
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003010 if (IsArrow) {
3011 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003012 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003013 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3014 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003015 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3016 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3017 // struct MyRecord foo;
3018 // foo->bar
3019 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3020 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3021 // by now.
3022 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3023 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003024 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003025 IsArrow = false;
3026 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003027 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3028 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3029 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003030 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003031 } else {
3032 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3033 // type *foo;
3034 // foo.bar
3035 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3036 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3037 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3038 // the appropriate pointer type
3039 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3040 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3041 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3042 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3043 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003044 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003045 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3046 IsArrow = true;
3047 }
3048 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003049 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003050
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003051 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003052 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003053 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3054 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003055 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003056 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003057 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003058
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003059 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3060 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003061 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003062 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003063 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003064 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3065 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3066 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3067 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003068 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3069
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003070 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003071 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003072
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003073 if (!IV) {
3074 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3075 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3076 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003077 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003078 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003079 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003080 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3081 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003082 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3083 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003084 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003085 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003086 }
3087 }
3088
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003089 if (IV) {
3090 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3091 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3092 // error cases.
3093 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3094 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003095
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003096 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3097 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3098 return ExprError();
3099 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3100 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3101 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3102 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3103 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3104 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3105 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3106 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3107 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3108 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3109 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3110 // AST for a function decl.
3111 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003112 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003113 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3114 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3115 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3116 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3117 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3118 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003119
3120 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3121 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003122 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003123 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003124 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003125 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3126 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003127 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003128 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003129 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003130
3131 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3132 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003134 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003135 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003136 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003137 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003138 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003139 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003140 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003141 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3142 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003143 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003144 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003145
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003146 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003147 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003148 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3149 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3150 // Check the use of this declaration
3151 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3152 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003153
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003154 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3155 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3156 }
3157 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3158 // Check the use of this method.
3159 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3160 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003161
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003162 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003163 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3164 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3165 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003166 }
3167 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003168
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003169 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003170 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003171 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003172
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003173 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3174 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003175 if (!IsArrow)
3176 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3177 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003178 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003179
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003180 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003181 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003182 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3183 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003184 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003185 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003186 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003187
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003188 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003189 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003190 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003191 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3192 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003193 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003194 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003195 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003196 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003197
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003198 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3199 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3200
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003201 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003202}
3203
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003204/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3205/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3206/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3207/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3208/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3209///
3210/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3211/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3212/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3213/// only be called
3214/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3215/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3216/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3217Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3218 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3219 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003220 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003221 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3222 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3223 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3224 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3225 return ExprError();
3226
3227 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3228
3229 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3230 DeclarationName Name;
3231 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3232 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3233 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3234 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3235
3236 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3237
3238 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3239 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3240 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3241
3242 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3243 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3244
3245 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3246 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003247 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3248 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003249 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003250 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3251 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3252 Name, NameLoc,
3253 TemplateArgs);
3254 } else {
3255 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3256 if (TemplateArgs) {
3257 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3258 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003259
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003260 // Re-derive the naming class.
3261 if (SS.isSet()) {
3262 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3263 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3264 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3265 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3266 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3267 } else {
3268 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3269 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3270 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3271 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3272 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3273 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003274 } else {
3275 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003276 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003277
3278 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3279 Owned(Base);
3280 return ExprError();
3281 }
3282
3283 if (Result.get()) {
3284 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3285 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3286 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3287 // call now.
3288 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3289 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003290 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003291
3292 return move(Result);
3293 }
3294 }
3295
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003296 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003297 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3298 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003299 }
3300
3301 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003302}
3303
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003304Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3305 FunctionDecl *FD,
3306 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3307 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3308 Diag (CallLoc,
3309 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3310 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003311 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003312 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3313 } else {
3314 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3315 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3316
3317 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003318 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3319 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003320
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003321 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3322 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003323 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003324
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003325 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003326 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003327 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003328
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003329 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3330 InitializedEntity Entity
3331 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3332 InitializationKind Kind
3333 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3334 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3335 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3336
3337 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003338 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003339 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3340 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003341 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003342
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003343 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003344 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003345 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003346 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003347
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003348 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3349 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3350 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003351 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3352 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003353 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3354 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003355 }
3356
3357 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003358 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003359}
3360
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003361/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3362/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3363/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3364/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3365/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3366/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003367bool
3368Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003369 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003370 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003371 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3372 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003373 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003374 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3375 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003376 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003377
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003378 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3379 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3380 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3381 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3382 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003383 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003384 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003385 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003386 }
3387
3388 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3389 // them.
3390 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3391 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3392 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3393 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003394 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003395 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003396 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3397 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3398 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003399 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003400 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003401 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003402 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003403 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003404 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003405 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3406 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3407 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3408 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3409 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003410 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003411 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003412 if (Invalid)
3413 return true;
3414 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3415 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3416 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003417
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003418 return false;
3419}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003420
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003421bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3422 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3423 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3424 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3425 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3426 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003427 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003428 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3429 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3430 bool Invalid = false;
3431 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3432 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3433 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3434 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003435 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003436 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003437 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003438
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003439 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003440 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3441 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003442
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003443 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3444 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003445 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003446 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003447 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003448
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003449 // Pass the argument
3450 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3451 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3452 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003453
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003454
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003455 InitializedEntity Entity =
3456 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3457 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3458 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3459 SourceLocation(),
3460 Owned(Arg));
3461 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3462 return true;
3463
3464 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003465 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003466 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003467
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003468 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003469 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003470 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3471 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003472
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003473 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003474 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003475 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003476 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003477
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003479 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003480 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003481 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i < NumArgs; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00003483 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003484 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003485 }
3486 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003487 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003488}
3489
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003490/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003491/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3492/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003493Action::OwningExprResult
3494Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3495 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003496 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003497 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003498
3499 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3500 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003501
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003502 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003503 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003504 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003505
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003506 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003507 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3508 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3509 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3510 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3511 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003512 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003513 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3514 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003515
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003516 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3517 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003518
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003519 NumArgs = 0;
3520 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003521
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003522 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3523 RParenLoc));
3524 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003525
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003526 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003527 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003528 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3529 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003530 bool Dependent = false;
3531 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3532 Dependent = true;
3533 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3534 Dependent = true;
3535
3536 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003537 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003538 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3539
3540 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3541 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3542 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3543 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3544
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003545 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3546
3547 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3548 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3549 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3550 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3551 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3552 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3553 // method template.
3554 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003555 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3556 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003557 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003558
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003559 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3560 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003561 }
3562
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003563 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003564 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003565 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003566 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003567 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3568 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003569 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003570
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003571 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003572 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003573 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3574 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003575 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3576 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003577 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003578
3579 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3580 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003581 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3582 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003583
3584 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3585 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003586 TheCall.get(), 0))
3587 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003588
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003589 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003590 RParenLoc))
3591 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003592
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003593 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3594 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003595 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003596 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3597 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003598 }
3599 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003600 }
3601
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003602 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003603 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003604 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003605
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003606 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003607 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3608 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003609 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003610 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003611 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003612
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003613 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3614 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3615 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3616
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003617 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3618}
3619
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003620/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3621/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003622/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3623/// block-pointer type.
3624///
3625/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3626Sema::OwningExprResult
3627Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3628 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3629 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3630 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3631 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3632
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003633 // Promote the function operand.
3634 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3635
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003636 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3637 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003638 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3639 Args, NumArgs,
3640 Context.BoolTy,
3641 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003642
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003643 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3644 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3645 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3646 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003647 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003648 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003649 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3650 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003651 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003652 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003653 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003654 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003655 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003656 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003657 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3658 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3659
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003660 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003661 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003662 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3663 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003664 return ExprError();
3665
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003666 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003667 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003668
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003669 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003670 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003671 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003672 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003673 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003674 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003675
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003676 if (FDecl) {
3677 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3678 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3679 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003680 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003681 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003682 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003683 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3684 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3685 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3686 }
3687 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003688 }
3689
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003690 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003691 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3692 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3693 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003694 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3695 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003696 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3697 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003698 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003699 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003700 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003701 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003702
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003703 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3704 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003705 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3706 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003707
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003708 // Check for sentinels
3709 if (NDecl)
3710 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003711
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003712 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003713 if (FDecl) {
3714 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3715 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003716
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003717 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003718 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3719 } else if (NDecl) {
3720 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3721 return ExprError();
3722 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003723
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003724 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003725}
3726
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003727Action::OwningExprResult
3728Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3729 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003730 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003731 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003732 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003733
3734 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3735 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3736 if (!TInfo)
3737 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3738
3739 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3740}
3741
3742Action::OwningExprResult
3743Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3744 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3745 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003746 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003747
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003748 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003749 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003750 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3751 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003752 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3753 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003754 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003755 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003756 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003757 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003758
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003759 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003760 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003761 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003762 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003763 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003764 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3765 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3766 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3767 &literalType);
3768 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003769 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003770 InitExpr.release();
3771 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003772
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003773 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003774 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003775 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003776 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003777 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003778
3779 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003780
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003781 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003782 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003783}
3784
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003785Action::OwningExprResult
3786Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003787 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3788 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3789 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003790
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003791 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003792 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003793
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003794 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3795 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003796 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003797 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003798}
3799
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003800static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3801 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003802 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003803 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3804
3805 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3806 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003807 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3808 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003809 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003810 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3811 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3812 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003813
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003814 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3815 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3816 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3817 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3818 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3819 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3820 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3821 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003822
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003823 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3824 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3825 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3826 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3827 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3828 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003829
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003830 // FIXME: Assert here.
3831 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3832 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3833}
3834
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003835/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003836bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003837 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003838 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003839 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003840 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003841 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3842 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003843
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003844 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003845
3846 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3847 // type needs to be scalar.
3848 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3849 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003850 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3851 return false;
3852 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003853
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003854 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003855 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003856 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3857 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003858 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003859 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3860 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003861 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003862 return false;
3863 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003864
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003865 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003866 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003867 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003868 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003869 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003870 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003871 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003872 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003873 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3874 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3875 break;
3876 }
3877 }
3878 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3879 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3880 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003881 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003882 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003883 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003884
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003885 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3886 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3887 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3888 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003889
3890 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003891 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003892 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3893 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003894 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003895 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003896
3897 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003898 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003899
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003900 if (castType->isVectorType())
3901 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3902 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3903 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3904
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003905 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3906 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003907
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003908 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003909 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3910 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3911 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3912 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3913 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3914 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3915 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3916 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3917 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3918 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003919 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920
3921 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003922 return false;
3923}
3924
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003925bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3926 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003927 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003928
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003929 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003930 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003931 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003932 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003933 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003934 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003935 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003936 } else
3937 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003938 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003939 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003940
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003941 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003942 return false;
3943}
3944
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003945bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003946 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003947 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003948
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003949 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003950
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003951 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3952 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003953 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3954 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3955 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3956 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003957 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003958 return false;
3959 }
3960
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003961 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003962 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3963 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003964 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3965 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3966 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3967 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003968
3969 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3970 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3971 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003972
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003973 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003974 return false;
3975}
3976
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003977Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003978Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003979 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3980 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3981 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003982
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003983 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3984 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3985 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003986 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003987
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003988 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003989 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003990 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003991 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3992 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003993
3994 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3995}
3996
3997Action::OwningExprResult
3998Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3999 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4000 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4001
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004002 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004003 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004004 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004005 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004006 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004007
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004008 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004009 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004010 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004011 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004012}
4013
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004014/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4015/// of comma binary operators.
4016Action::OwningExprResult
4017Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4018 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4019 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4020 if (!E)
4021 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004022
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004023 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004024
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004025 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4026 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4027 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004028
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004029 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4030}
4031
4032Action::OwningExprResult
4033Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4034 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004035 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004036 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004037 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004038
4039 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004040 // then handle it as such.
4041 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4042 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4043 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4044 return ExprError();
4045 }
4046
4047 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4048 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4049 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4050
4051 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4052 // braces instead of the original commas.
4053 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004054 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4055 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004056 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4057 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004058 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004059 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004060 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004061 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4062 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004063 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064 }
4065}
4066
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004067Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004068 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004069 MultiExprArg Val,
4070 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004071 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4072 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004073 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4074 Expr *expr;
4075 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4076 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4077 else
4078 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004079 return Owned(expr);
4080}
4081
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004082/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4083/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004084/// C99 6.5.15
4085QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4086 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004087 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4088 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4089 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4090
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004091 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4092 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4093 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4094 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4095 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4096 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004097
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004098 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004099 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4100 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4101 << CondTy;
4102 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004103 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004104
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004105 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004106 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4107 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004108
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004109 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4110 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004111 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4112 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4113 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004114 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004115
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004116 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4117 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004118 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4119 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004120 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004121 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004122 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004123 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004124 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004125 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004126
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004127 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004128 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004129 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4130 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4131 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4132 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4133 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4134 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4135 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004136 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4137 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004138 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004139 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004140 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4141 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004142 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004143 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004144 // promote the null to a pointer.
4145 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004146 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004147 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004148 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004149 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004150 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004151 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004152 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004153
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004154 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4155 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4156 QuestionLoc);
4157 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4158 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004159
4160
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004161 // Handle block pointer types.
4162 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4163 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4164 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4165 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004166 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4167 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004168 return destType;
4169 }
4170 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004171 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004172 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004173 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004174 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4175 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4176 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004177 return LHSTy;
4178 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004180 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4181 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004182
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004183 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4184 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004185 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004186 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004187 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4188 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4189 // to get a consistent AST.
4190 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004191 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4192 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004193 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004194 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004195 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004196 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4197 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004198 return LHSTy;
4199 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004200
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004201 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4202 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4203 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004204 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4205 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004206
4207 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4208 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4209 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004210 QualType destPointee
4211 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004212 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004213 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4214 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4215 // Promote to void*.
4216 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004217 return destType;
4218 }
4219 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004220 QualType destPointee
4221 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004222 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004223 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004224 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004225 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004226 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004227 return destType;
4228 }
4229
4230 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4231 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4232 return LHSTy;
4233 }
4234 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4235 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4236 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4237 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4238 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4239 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4240 // to get a consistent AST.
4241 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004242 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4243 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004244 return incompatTy;
4245 }
4246 // The pointer types are compatible.
4247 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4248 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4249 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4250 // type.
4251 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4252 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004253 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4254 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004255 return LHSTy;
4256 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004257
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004258 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4259 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4260 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4261 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004262 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004263 return RHSTy;
4264 }
4265 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4266 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4267 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004268 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004269 return LHSTy;
4270 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004271
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004272 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004273 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4274 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004275 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004276}
4277
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004278/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4279/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4280QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4281 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4282 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4283 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004284
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004285 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4286 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4287 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4288 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4289 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4290 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4291 return LHSTy;
4292 }
4293 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4294 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4295 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4296 return RHSTy;
4297 }
4298 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4299 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4300 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4301 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4302 return LHSTy;
4303 }
4304 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4305 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4306 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4307 return RHSTy;
4308 }
4309 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4310 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4311 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4312 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4313 return LHSTy;
4314 }
4315 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4316 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4317 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4318 return RHSTy;
4319 }
4320 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4321 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004322
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004323 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4324 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4325 return LHSTy;
4326 }
4327 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4328 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4329 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004330
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004331 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4332 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4333 // type. This allows
4334 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4335 // where B is a subclass of A.
4336 //
4337 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4338 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4339 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4340 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004341
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004342 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4343 // It could return the composite type.
4344 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4345 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4346 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4347 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4348 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4349 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4350 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4351 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4352 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4353 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4354 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4355 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4356 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4357 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004358 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004359 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4360 ;
4361 else {
4362 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4363 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4364 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4365 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4366 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4367 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4368 return incompatTy;
4369 }
4370 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4371 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4372 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4373 return compositeType;
4374 }
4375 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4376 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4377 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4378 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4379 QualType destPointee
4380 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4381 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4382 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4383 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4384 // Promote to void*.
4385 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4386 return destType;
4387 }
4388 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4389 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4390 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4391 QualType destPointee
4392 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4393 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4394 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4395 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4396 // Promote to void*.
4397 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4398 return destType;
4399 }
4400 return QualType();
4401}
4402
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004403/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004404/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004405Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4406 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4407 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4408 ExprArg RHS) {
4409 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4410 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004411
4412 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4413 // was the condition.
4414 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4415 if (isLHSNull)
4416 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004417
4418 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004419 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004420 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004421 return ExprError();
4422
4423 Cond.release();
4424 LHS.release();
4425 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004426 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004427 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004428 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004429}
4430
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004431// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004432// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004433// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4434// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4435// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004436Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004437Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004438 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004439
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004440 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4441 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4442 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4443 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4444 return Compatible;
4445 }
4446
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004447 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004448 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4449 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004450
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004451 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004452 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4453 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004454
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004455 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004456
4457 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4458 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4459 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004460 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004461 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004462 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004463
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004464 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4465 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004466 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004467 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004468 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004469 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004470
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004471 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004472 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4473 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004474 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004475
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004476 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004477 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004478 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004479
4480 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004481 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4482 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004483 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004484 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004485 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004486 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4487 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4488 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4489 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4490 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4491 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004492 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004493 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004494 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004495 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004496
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004497 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004498 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004499 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004500 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004501
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004502 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4503 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4504 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4505 // warning can be disabled.
4506 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4507 return ConvTy;
4508 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4509 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004510
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004511 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4512 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4513 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4514 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4515 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4516 do {
4517 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4518 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004520 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4521 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4522 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004523
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004524 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004525 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004526 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004527
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004528 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004529 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004530 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004531 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004532}
4533
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004534/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4535/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4536/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4537// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538Sema::AssignConvertType
4539Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004540 QualType rhsType) {
4541 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004543 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004544 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4545 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004547 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4548 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4549 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004550
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004551 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004553 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004554 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004555 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004556
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004557 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4558 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4559 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4560 }
4561 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004562 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004563 return ConvTy;
4564}
4565
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004566/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4567/// for assignment compatibility.
4568Sema::AssignConvertType
4569Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004570 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4571 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004572 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4573 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004574 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004575 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004576 }
4577 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4578 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004579 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4580 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004581 return IncompatiblePointer;
4582 return Compatible;
4583 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004584 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004585 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004586 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004587 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4588 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4589 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4590 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4591 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4592 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004593
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004594 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4595 return Compatible;
4596 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4597 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004598 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004599}
4600
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004601/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4602/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004603/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4604///
4605/// int a, *pint;
4606/// short *pshort;
4607/// struct foo *pfoo;
4608///
4609/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4610/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4611/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4612/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4613///
4614/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004615/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004616///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004617Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004618Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004619 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4620 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004621 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4622 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004623
4624 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004625 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004626
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004627 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4628 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4629 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4630 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4631 return Compatible;
4632 }
4633
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004634 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4635 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4636 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4637 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4638 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4639 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4640 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004641 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004642 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004643 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004644 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004645 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004646 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4647 // to the same ExtVector type.
4648 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4649 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4650 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4651 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4652 return Compatible;
4653 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004654
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004655 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004656 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004657 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004658 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004659 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4660 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004661 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004662 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004663 }
4664 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004665 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004666
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004667 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004668 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004669
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004670 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004671 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004672 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004673
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004674 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004675 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004676
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004677 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004678 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004679 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4680 return Compatible;
4681 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004682 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004683 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4684 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004685 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004686
4687 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004688 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004689 return Compatible;
4690 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004691 return Incompatible;
4692 }
4693
4694 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4695 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004696 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004697
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004698 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004699 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004700 return Compatible;
4701
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004702 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4703 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004704
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004705 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004706 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004707 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004708 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004709 return Incompatible;
4710 }
4711
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004712 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4713 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4714 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004715
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004716 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004717 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004718 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4719 return Compatible;
4720 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004721 }
4722 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004723 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004724 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004725 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004726 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4727 return Compatible;
4728 }
4729 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4730 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4731 return Compatible;
4732 return Incompatible;
4733 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004734 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004735 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004736 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4737 return Compatible;
4738
4739 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004740 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004741
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004742 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004743 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004744
4745 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004746 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004747 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004748 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004749 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004750 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4751 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4752 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4753 return Compatible;
4754
4755 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4756 return PointerToInt;
4757
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004758 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004759 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004760 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4761 return Compatible;
4762 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004763 }
4764 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004765 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004766 return Compatible;
4767 return Incompatible;
4768 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004769
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004770 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004771 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004772 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004773 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004774 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004775}
4776
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004777/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4778/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004779static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004780 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4781 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4782 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004783 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004784 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004785 SourceLocation());
4786 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4787 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4788
4789 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4790 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004791 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004792 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004793 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004794}
4795
4796Sema::AssignConvertType
4797Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4798 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4799
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004800 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004801 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4802 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004803 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004804 return Incompatible;
4805
4806 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4807 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4808 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4809 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004810 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4811 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004812 it != itend; ++it) {
4813 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4814 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4815 // 1) void pointer
4816 // 2) null pointer constant
4817 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004818 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004819 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004820 InitField = *it;
4821 break;
4822 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004823
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004824 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004825 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004826 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004827 InitField = *it;
4828 break;
4829 }
4830 }
4831
4832 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4833 == Compatible) {
4834 InitField = *it;
4835 break;
4836 }
4837 }
4838
4839 if (!InitField)
4840 return Incompatible;
4841
4842 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4843 return Compatible;
4844}
4845
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004846Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004847Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004848 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4849 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4850 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4851 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4852 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004853 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004854 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004855 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004856 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004857 }
4858
4859 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4860 // structures.
4861 }
4862
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004863 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4864 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004865 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4866 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004867 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004868 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004869 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004870 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004871 return Compatible;
4872 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004873
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004874 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004875 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004876 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004877 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004878 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004879 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004880 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004881 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004882
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004883 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4884 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004885
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004886 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4887 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004888 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4889 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4890 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4891 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004892 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004893 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4894 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004895 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004896}
4897
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004898QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004899 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004900 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004901 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004902 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004903}
4904
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004905QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004906 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004907 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004908 QualType lhsType =
4909 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4910 QualType rhsType =
4911 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004912
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004913 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004914 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004915 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004916
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004917 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4918 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004919 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4920 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004921 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4922 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004923 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004924 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004925 return lhsType->isExtVectorType() ? lhsType : rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004926 }
4927 }
4928 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004929
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004930 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4931 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4932 bool swapped = false;
4933 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4934 swapped = true;
4935 std::swap(rex, lex);
4936 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4937 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004938
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004939 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004940 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004941 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4942 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4943 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004944 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004945 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4946 return lhsType;
4947 }
4948 }
4949 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4950 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4951 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004952 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004953 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4954 return lhsType;
4955 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004956 }
4957 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004958
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004959 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004960 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004961 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004962 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004963 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004964}
4965
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004966QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4967 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004968 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004969 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004970
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004971 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004972
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004973 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4974 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4975 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004976
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004977 // Check for division by zero.
4978 if (isDiv &&
4979 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004980 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004981 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004982
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004983 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004984}
4985
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004986QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004987 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004988 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4989 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4990 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4991 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4992 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004993
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004994 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004995
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004996 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4997 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004998
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999 // Check for remainder by zero.
5000 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005001 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5002 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005003
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005004 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005005}
5006
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005007QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005008 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005009 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5010 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5011 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5012 return compType;
5013 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005014
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005015 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005016
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005017 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005018 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5019 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5020 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005021 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005022 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005023
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005024 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5025 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005026 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005027 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5028
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005029 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005030
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005031 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005032 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005033
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005034 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5035 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005036 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5037 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005038 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005039 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005040 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005041
5042 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5043 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5044 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005045 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005046 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5047 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5048 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5049 return QualType();
5050 }
5051
5052 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5053 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5054 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005055 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005056 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005057 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005058 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005059 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5060 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005061 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5062 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005063 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005064 return QualType();
5065 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005066 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005067 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005068 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5069 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5070 return QualType();
5071 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005072
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005073 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005074 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5075 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5076 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5077 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5078 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005079 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005080 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5081 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005082 return PExp->getType();
5083 }
5084 }
5085
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005086 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005087}
5088
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005089// C99 6.5.6
5090QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5092 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5093 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5094 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5095 return compType;
5096 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005097
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005098 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005099
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005100 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005101
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005102 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005103 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5104 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005105 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005106 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005107 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005108
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005109 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005110 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005111 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005113 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005114
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005115 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5116 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5117 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5118 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5119 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5120 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5121 return QualType();
5122 }
5123
5124 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5125 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5126 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5127 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5128 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005129 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005130 return QualType();
5131 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005132
5133 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5134 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5135 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005136 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005137 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005138 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005139 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005140 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005141
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005142 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005143 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5145 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5146 return QualType();
5147 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005148
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005149 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005150 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5151 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5152 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5153 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5154 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5155 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005156 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005157 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5158
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005159 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005160 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005161 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005162
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005163 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005164 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005165 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005166
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005167 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5168 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5169 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5170 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5171 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5172 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5173 return QualType();
5174 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005175
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005176 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5177 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5178 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5179 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005180 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005181 return QualType();
5182 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005183
5184 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5185 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5186 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5187 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5188 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005189 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5190 << rex->getSourceRange()
5191 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005192 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005193
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005194 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5195 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5196 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5197 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5198 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5199 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5200 return QualType();
5201 }
5202 } else {
5203 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5204 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5205 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5206 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5207 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5208 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5209 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5210 return QualType();
5211 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005212 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005213
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005214 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5215 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5216 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5217 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5218 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005219 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005220 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005221
5222 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005223 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5224 }
5225 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005226
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005227 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005228}
5229
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005230// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005231QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005232 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005233 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5234 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005235 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005236
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005237 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5238 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5239 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5240
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005241 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5242 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005243 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5244 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5245 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5246 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5247 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005248 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005249 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005250 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005251
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005252 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005253
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005254 // Sanity-check shift operands
5255 llvm::APSInt Right;
5256 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005257 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5258 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005259 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005260 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5261 else {
5262 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5263 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5264 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5265 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5266 }
5267 }
5268
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005269 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005270 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005271}
5272
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005273// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005274QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005275 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5276 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5277
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005278 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005279 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005280 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005281
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005282 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005283 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5284 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5285 else {
5286 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5287 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5288 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005289 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5290 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005291
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005292 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5293 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005294 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5295 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5296 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005297 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005298 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005299 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5300 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5301 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5302 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005303 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5304 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005305 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005306
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005307 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5308 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5309 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5310 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005311
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005312 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5313 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005314 Expr *literalString = 0;
5315 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005316 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005317 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005318 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005319 literalString = lex;
5320 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005321 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5322 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005323 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005324 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005325 literalString = rex;
5326 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5327 }
5328
5329 if (literalString) {
5330 std::string resultComparison;
5331 switch (Opc) {
5332 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5333 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5334 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5335 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5336 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5337 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5338 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5339 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005340
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005341 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5342 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5343 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005344 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005345 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005346 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005347
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005348 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005349 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005350
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005351 if (isRelational) {
5352 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005353 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005354 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005355 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005356 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005357 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005359 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005360 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005361 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005362
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005363 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005364 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005365 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005366 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005367
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005368 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5369 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5370 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005371 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005372 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005373 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005374 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005375 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005376
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005377 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005378 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5379 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005380 if (!isRelational &&
5381 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5382 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5383 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5384 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5385 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5386 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5387 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5388 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5389 return ResultTy;
5390 }
5391 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005392 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5393 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5394 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5395 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5396 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5397 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005398 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005399 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005400 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005401 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005402 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005403 if (T.isNull()) {
5404 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5405 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5406 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005407 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005408 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005409 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005410 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005411 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005412 }
5413
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005414 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5415 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005416 return ResultTy;
5417 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005418 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5419 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5420 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5421 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5422 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5423 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5424 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5425 }
5426 } else if (!isRelational &&
5427 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5428 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5429 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5430 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5431 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5432 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5433 }
5434 } else {
5435 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005436 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005437 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005438 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005439 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005440 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005441 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005442 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005444 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005445 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005446 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005447 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005448 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5449 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005450 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005451 return ResultTy;
5452 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005453 if (LHSIsNull &&
5454 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5455 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005456 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005457 return ResultTy;
5458 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005459
5460 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005461 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005462 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5463 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005464 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5465 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5466 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5467 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5468 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5469 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5470 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5471 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005472 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005473 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005474 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005475 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005476 if (T.isNull()) {
5477 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005478 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005479 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005480 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005481 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005482 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005483 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005484 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005485 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005486
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005487 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5488 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005489 return ResultTy;
5490 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005491
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005492 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005493 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5494 return ResultTy;
5495 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005496
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005497 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005498 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005499 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5500 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005501
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005502 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005503 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005504 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005505 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005506 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005507 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005508 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005509 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005510 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005511 if (!isRelational
5512 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5513 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005514 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005515 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005516 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005517 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005518 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5519 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5520 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005521 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005522 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005523 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005524 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005525
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005526 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005527 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005528 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5529 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005530 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005531 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005532 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005533 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005534
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005535 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5536 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005537 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005538 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005539 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005540 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005541 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005542 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005543 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005544 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005545 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5546 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005547 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005548 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005549 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005550 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005551 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005552 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5553 if (RHSIsNull) {
5554 if (isRelational)
5555 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5556 } else if (isRelational)
5557 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5558 else
5559 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005560
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005561 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005562 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005563 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005564 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005565 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005566 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005567 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005568 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005569 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5570 if (LHSIsNull) {
5571 if (isRelational)
5572 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5573 } else if (isRelational)
5574 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5575 else
5576 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005577
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005578 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005579 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005580 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005581 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005582 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005583 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005584 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005585 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005586 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5587 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005588 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005589 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005590 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005591 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5592 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005593 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005594 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005595 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005596 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005597}
5598
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005599/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005600/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005601/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5602/// types.
5603QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005604 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005605 bool isRelational) {
5606 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5607 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005608 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005609 if (vType.isNull())
5610 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005611
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005612 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5613 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005614
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005615 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5616 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5617 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5618 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5619 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5620 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5621 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005622 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005623 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005624
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005625 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5626 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5627 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005628 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005629 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005630
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005631 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5632 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5633 // elements for floating point vectors.
5634 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5635 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005636
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005637 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005638 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005639 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005640 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005641 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005642 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5643
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005644 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005645 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005646 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5647}
5648
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005649inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005650 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005651 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005652 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005653
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005654 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005655
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005656 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005657 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005658 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005659}
5660
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005661inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005662 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005663 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5664 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5665 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005666
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005667 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5668 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005669
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005670 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005671 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005672
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005673 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5674 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5675 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5676 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5677 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5678 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5679 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005680
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005681 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005682 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005683 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005684
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005685 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5686 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5687 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5688 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005689
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005690 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005691 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005692 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005693
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005694 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5695 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5696 // The result is a bool.
5697 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005698}
5699
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005700/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5701/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5702/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5703///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005704static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005705 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5706 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5707 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5708 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005709 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005710 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5711 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5712 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5713 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005714 }
5715 }
5716 return false;
5717}
5718
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005719/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5720/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5721static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005722 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005723 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005724 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005725 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5726 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005727 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5728 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005729
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005730 unsigned Diag = 0;
5731 bool NeedType = false;
5732 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005733 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005734 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005735 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5736 NeedType = true;
5737 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005738 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005739 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5740 NeedType = true;
5741 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005742 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005743 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5744 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005745 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5746 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005747 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005748 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5749 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005750 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5751 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005752 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5753 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005754 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005755 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005756 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005757 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005758 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5759 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005760 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005761 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5762 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005763 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5764 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5765 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005766 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5767 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5768 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005769 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5770 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5771 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005772 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005773
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005774 SourceRange Assign;
5775 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5776 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005777 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005778 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005779 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005780 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005781 return true;
5782}
5783
5784
5785
5786// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005787QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5788 SourceLocation Loc,
5789 QualType CompoundType) {
5790 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5791 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005792 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005793
5794 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5795 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005796
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005797 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005798 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005799 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005800 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005801 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5802 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5803 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005804 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005805 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005806 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005807 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005808
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005809 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5810 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5811 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005812 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005813 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5814 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5815 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5816 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5817 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005818 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005819 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005820 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5821 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5822 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005823 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5824 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005825 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5826 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5827 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005828 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005829 }
5830 } else {
5831 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005832 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005833 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005834
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005835 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005836 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005837 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005838
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005839 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5840 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005841 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005842 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5843 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005844 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005845 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005846 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005847}
5848
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005849// C99 6.5.17
5850QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005851 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005852 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5853 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5854 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005855
5856 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5857 // incomplete in C++).
5858
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005859 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005860}
5861
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005862/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5863/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005864QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005865 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005866 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5867 return Context.DependentTy;
5868
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005869 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5870 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005871
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005872 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5873 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5874 if (!isInc) {
5875 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5876 return QualType();
5877 }
5878 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5879 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5880 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005881 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005882 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5883 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005884
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005885 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005886 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005887 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5888 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5889 << Op->getSourceRange();
5890 return QualType();
5891 }
5892
5893 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005894 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005895 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005896 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5897 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5898 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5899 return QualType();
5900 }
5901
5902 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005903 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005904 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005905 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005906 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005907 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005908 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005909 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005910 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005911 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5912 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5913 return QualType();
5914 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005915 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005916 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5917 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005918 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005919 } else {
5920 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005921 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005922 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005923 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005924 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005925 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005926 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005927 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005928 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5929 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5930 // operand.
5931 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5932 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005933}
5934
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005935/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005936/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005937/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5938/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5939/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5940/// - &(x) => x
5941/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5942/// - &s.xx => s
5943/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5944/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5945/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5946/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005947static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005948 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005949 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005950 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005951 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005952 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5953 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5954 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005955 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005956 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005957 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005958 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005959 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005960 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5961 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005962 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5963 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5964 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5965 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5966 }
5967 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005968 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005969 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5970 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005971
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005972 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005973 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5974 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5975 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5976 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5977 default:
5978 return 0;
5979 }
5980 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005981 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005982 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005983 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005984 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5985 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005986 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005987 default:
5988 return 0;
5989 }
5990}
5991
5992/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005993/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005994/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005995/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00005996/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005997/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00005998/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005999QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006000 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6001 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6002
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006003 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6004 return Context.DependentTy;
6005
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006006 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6007 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6008 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6009 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6010 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6011 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6012 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6013 }
6014 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6015 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6016 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006017 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006018 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006019
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006020 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6021 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6022 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6023 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6024 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6025 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6026 // branch of the if, below.
6027 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6028 << dcl;
6029 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6030
6031 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6032 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6033 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6034 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006035 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6036 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6037 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6038 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6039 if (isSFINAEContext())
6040 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006041 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006042 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006043 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006044 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006045 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006046 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6047 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006048 return QualType();
6049 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006050 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006051 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6053 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006054 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006055 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006056 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006057 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006058 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006059 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006060 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6061 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6062 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6063 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6064 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006065 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6066 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006067 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6068 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006069 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6070 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006071 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006072 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006073 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6074 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006075 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006076 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6077 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006078 return QualType();
6079 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006080 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006081 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006082 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006083 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006084 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6085 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006086 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006087 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006088 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6089 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006090 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006091 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6092 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6093 return QualType();
6094 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006095
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006096 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6097 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006098 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006099 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006100 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006101 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006102 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006103 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6104 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006105 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6106 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6107 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006108 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006109 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006110
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006111 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6112 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6113 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6114 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6116 }
6117
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006118 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006119 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006120}
6121
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006122QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006123 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6124 return Context.DependentTy;
6125
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006126 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6127 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006128
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006129 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6130 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6131 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6132 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006133 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006134 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006135
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006136 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006137 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006138
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006140 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006141 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006142}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006143
6144static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6145 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6146 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6147 switch (Kind) {
6148 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006149 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6150 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006151 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6152 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6153 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6154 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6155 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6156 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6157 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6158 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6159 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6160 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6161 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6162 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6163 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6164 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6165 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6166 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6167 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6168 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6169 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6170 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6171 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6172 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6173 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6174 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6175 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6176 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6177 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6178 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6179 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6180 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6181 }
6182 return Opc;
6183}
6184
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006185static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6186 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6187 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6188 switch (Kind) {
6189 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6190 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6191 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6192 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6193 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6194 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6195 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6196 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6197 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006198 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6199 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006200 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006201 }
6202 return Opc;
6203}
6204
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006205/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6206/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6207/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006208Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6209 unsigned Op,
6210 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006211 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006212 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006213 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6214 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6215 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006216
6217 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006218 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6219 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6220 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006221 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6222 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6223 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6224 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6225 break;
6226 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006227 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006228 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6229 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006230 break;
6231 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6232 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6233 break;
6234 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6235 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6236 break;
6237 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6238 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6239 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006240 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006241 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6242 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6243 break;
6244 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6245 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6246 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6247 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006248 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006249 break;
6250 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6251 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006252 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006253 break;
6254 case BinaryOperator::And:
6255 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6256 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6257 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6258 break;
6259 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6260 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6261 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6262 break;
6263 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6264 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006265 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6266 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006267 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6268 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6269 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006270 break;
6271 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006272 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6273 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6274 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6275 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006276 break;
6277 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006278 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6279 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6280 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006281 break;
6282 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006283 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6284 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6285 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006286 break;
6287 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6288 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006289 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6290 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6291 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6292 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006293 break;
6294 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6295 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6296 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006297 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6298 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6299 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6300 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006301 break;
6302 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6303 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6304 break;
6305 }
6306 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006307 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006308 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006309 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6310 else
6311 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006312 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6313 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006314}
6315
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006316/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6317/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006318static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6319 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006320 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6321 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6322 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006323 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006324 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6325
6326 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6327 return;
6328
6329 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6330 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6331 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006332 return;
6333 }
6334
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006335 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6336 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006337 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006338
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006339 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006340 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006341
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006342 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6343 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6344 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6345 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006346 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006347 return;
6348 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006349
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006350 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006351 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6352 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006353}
6354
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006355/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6356/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6357/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6358/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006359static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6360 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006361 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6362 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6363 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6364 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006365 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006366 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006367 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6368
6369 // Subs are not binary operators.
6370 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6371 return;
6372
6373 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6374 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006375 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6376 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006377 return;
6378
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006379 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006380 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006381 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006382 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6383 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006384 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006385 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006386 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6387 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6388 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6389 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006390 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006391 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006392 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006393 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6394 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006395 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006396 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006397 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6398 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6399 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6400 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006401}
6402
6403/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6404/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6405/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6406static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6407 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006408 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006409 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6410}
6411
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006412// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006413Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6414 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6415 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006416 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006417 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006418
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006419 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6420 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006421
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006422 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6423 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6424
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006425 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6426}
6427
6428Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6429 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6430 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006431 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006432 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006433 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6434 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6435 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6436 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6437 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006438 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006439 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006440 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6441 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6442 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006443
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006444 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6445 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006446 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006447 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006448
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006449 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006450 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006451}
6452
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006453Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006454 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006455 ExprArg InputArg) {
6456 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006457
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006458 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006459 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006460 QualType resultType;
6461 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006462 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6463 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6464 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006465
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006466 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6467 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006468 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6469 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006470 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006471 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006472 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6473 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6474 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006475 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006476 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006477 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006478 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006479 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006480 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006481 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006482 break;
6483 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6484 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006485 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6486 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006487 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6488 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006489 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6490 break;
6491 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6492 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6493 break;
6494 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6495 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6496 resultType->isPointerType())
6497 break;
6498
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006499 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6500 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006501 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006502 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6503 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006504 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6505 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006506 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6507 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6508 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006509 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006510 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006511 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006512 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6513 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006514 break;
6515 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006516 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006517 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006518 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006519 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6520 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006521 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006522 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6523 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006524 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006525 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6526 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006527 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006528 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006529 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006530 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006531 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006532 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006533 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006534 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006535 }
6536 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006537 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006538
6539 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006540 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006541}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006542
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006543Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6544 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6545 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006546 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006547 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6548 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006549 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6550 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6551 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6552 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006553 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006554 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006555 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6556 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6557 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006558
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006559 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6560 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006561
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006562 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6563}
6564
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006565// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6566Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6567 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6568 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6569}
6570
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006571/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006572Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6573 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6574 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006575 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006576 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006577
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006578 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6579 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006580 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006581 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006582
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006583 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006584 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6585 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006586}
6587
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006588Sema::OwningExprResult
6589Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6590 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6591 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006592 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6593 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6594
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006595 bool isFileScope
6596 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006597 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006598 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006599
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006600 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6601 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6602 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006603
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006604 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6605 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6606 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006607
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006608 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6609 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6610 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6611 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6612 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006613
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006614 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006615 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006616 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006617
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006618 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6619 // expressions are not lvalues.
6620
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006621 substmt.release();
6622 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006623}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006624
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006625Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6626 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006627 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6628 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006629 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6630 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006631 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006632 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
6633
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006634 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6635 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6636 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006637 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006638 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6639 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6640
6641 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6642 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6643 if (!Dependent
6644 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6645 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6646 << TypeRange))
6647 return ExprError();
6648
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006649 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6650 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006651 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6652 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006653 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006654 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6655 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006656
6657 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6658 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6659 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6660 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6661 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6662 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6663 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6664 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6665 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6666 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6667 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6668 if(!AT)
6669 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6670 << CurrentType);
6671 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6672 } else
6673 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6674
6675 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6676 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6677 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6678 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6679 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6680 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6681 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6682 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6683
6684 // Record this array index.
6685 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6686 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6687 continue;
6688 }
6689
6690 // Offset of a field.
6691 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6692 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6693 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6694 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6695 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6696 continue;
6697 }
6698
6699 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6700 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6701 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6702 return ExprError();
6703
6704 // Look for the designated field.
6705 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6706 if (!RC)
6707 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6708 << CurrentType);
6709 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6710
6711 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6712 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6713 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6714 // (clause 9).
6715 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6716 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6717 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6718 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6719 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6720 << CurrentType))
6721 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6722 }
6723
6724 // Look for the field.
6725 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6726 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6727 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6728 if (!MemberDecl)
6729 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6730 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6731 OC.LocEnd));
6732
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006733 // C99 7.17p3:
6734 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6735 //
6736 // We diagnose this as an error.
6737 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6738 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6739 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6740 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6741 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6742 return ExprError();
6743 }
6744
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006745 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6746 // the base class indirections.
6747 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6748 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6749 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6750 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6751 Paths)) {
6752 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6753 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6754 B != BEnd; ++B)
6755 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6756 }
6757
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006758 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006759 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006760 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6761 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6762 unsigned n = Path.size();
6763 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6764 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6765 } else {
6766 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6767 }
6768 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6769 }
6770
6771 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6772 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6773 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6774}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006775
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006776Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6777 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6778 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6779 TypeTy *argty,
6780 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6781 unsigned NumComponents,
6782 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6783
6784 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6785 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6786 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6787 return ExprError();
6788
6789 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6790 if (!ArgTInfo)
6791 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6792
6793 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6794 RPLoc);
6795 }
6796
6797 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6798 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6799
6800 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6801
6802 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6803 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6804 // a struct/union/class.
6805 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6806 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6807
6808 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6809 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6810
6811 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6812 // the offsetof designators.
6813 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6814 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6815 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6816 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6817
6818 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6819 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6820 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6821 // a system header!
6822 if (NumComponents != 1)
6823 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6824 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6825
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006826 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006827 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006828
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006829 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6830 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6831 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006832
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006833 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6834 // leaks like a sieve.
6835 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6836 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6837 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6838 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6839 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6840 if (!AT) {
6841 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006842 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006843 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006844 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006845
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006846 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006847
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006848 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6849 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006850 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006851
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006852 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6853 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006854 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006855 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006856 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006857 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006858 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6859
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006860 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6861 OC.LocEnd);
6862 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006863 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006864
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006865 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 if (!RC) {
6867 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006868 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006869 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006870 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006871
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006872 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6873 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006874 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006875 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6876 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6877 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006878 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6879 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006880 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006881 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006882
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006883 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6884 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006885
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006886 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006887 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006888 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006889 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006890 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6891
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006892 // C99 7.17p3:
6893 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6894 //
6895 // We diagnose this as an error.
6896 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6897 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6898 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6899 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6900 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6901 return ExprError();
6902 }
6903
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006904 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6905 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006906 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006907 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006908 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006909 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006910 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6911 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006912 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6913 // doesn't matter here.
6914 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006915 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006916 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006917 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006918 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006919
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006920 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6921 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006922}
6923
6924
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006925Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6926 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6927 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006928 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6929 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6930 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006931
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006932 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006933
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006934 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6935 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6936 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6937 return ExprError();
6938 }
6939
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006940 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6941 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006942}
6943
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006944Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6945 ExprArg cond,
6946 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6947 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6948 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6949 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6950 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006951
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006952 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6953
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006954 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006955 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006956 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006957 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006958 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006959 } else {
6960 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6961 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6962 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6963 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006964 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6965 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6966 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006967
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006968 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6969 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006970 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6971 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006972 }
6973
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006974 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6975 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006976 resType, RPLoc,
6977 resType->isDependentType(),
6978 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006979}
6980
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006981//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6982// Clang Extensions.
6983//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6984
6985/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006986void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006987 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6988 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6989 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6990 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006991}
6992
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006993void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006994 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006995 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006996
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006997 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6998 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006999 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007000 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
7001
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00007002 if (T->isArrayType()) {
7003 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7004 diag::err_block_returns_array);
7005 return;
7006 }
7007
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007008 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
7009 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007010 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
7011 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007012
7013 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
7014 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007015 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007016 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007017 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007018 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007019 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7020 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007021 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007022
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007023 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007024 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007025 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7026 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7027 return;
7028 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007029
7030 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007031 return;
7032 }
7033
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007034 // Analyze arguments to block.
7035 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7036 "Not a function declarator!");
7037 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007038
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007039 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7040 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007041
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007042 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7043 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7044 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7045 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007046 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7047 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007048 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007049 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007050 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007051 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7052 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7053 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7054 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7055 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7056 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7057 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7058 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7059 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007060 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007061 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007062 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007063 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007064 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007065 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007066
7067 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7068 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7069
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007070 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007071 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7072 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7073
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007074 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007075 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7076 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7077 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7078
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007079 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007080 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007081 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007082
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007083 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007084 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007085 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007086 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007087 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007088 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7089 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007090
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007091 // Analyze the return type.
7092 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007093 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007094
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007095 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007096 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007097 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7098 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7099 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007100 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007101}
7102
7103/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7104/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7105void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007106 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007107 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007108 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007109 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007110}
7111
7112/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7113/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007114Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7115 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007116 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7117 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7118 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007119
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007120 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007121
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007122 PopDeclContext();
7123
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007124 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007125 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7126 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007127
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007128 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7129 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7130 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007131
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007132 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007133 QualType BlockTy;
7134 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007135 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007136 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007137 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007138 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007139 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007140 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007141
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007142 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007143 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007144 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007145
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007146 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007147 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007148 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007149
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007150 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007151
7152 bool Good = true;
7153 // Check goto/label use.
7154 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7155 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7156 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7157
7158 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7159 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7160 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7161 continue;
7162
7163 // Emit error.
7164 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7165 Good = false;
7166 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007167 if (!Good) {
7168 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007169 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007170 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007171
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007172 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007173 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7174 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7175 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007176
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007177 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7178 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007179 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007180 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007181}
7182
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007183Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7184 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7185 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007186 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007187 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7188 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007189
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007190 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007191
7192 // Get the va_list type
7193 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007194 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7195 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7196 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7197 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007198 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007199 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7200 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7201 } else {
7202 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7203 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007204 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007205 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007206 return ExprError();
7207 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007208
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007209 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7210 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007211 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7212 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007213 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007214 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007215
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007216 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007217 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007218
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007219 expr.release();
7220 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7221 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007222}
7223
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007224Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007225 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7226 // pointers on the target.
7227 QualType Ty;
7228 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7229 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7230 else
7231 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7232
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007233 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007234}
7235
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007236static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007237 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007238 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7239 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007240
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007241 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7242 if (!PT)
7243 return;
7244
7245 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7246 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7247 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7248 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7249 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7250 return;
7251 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007252
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007253 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7254 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7255 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7256 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007257
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007258 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007259}
7260
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007261bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7262 SourceLocation Loc,
7263 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007264 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7265 bool *Complained) {
7266 if (Complained)
7267 *Complained = false;
7268
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007269 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7270 bool isInvalid = false;
7271 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007272 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007273
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007274 switch (ConvTy) {
7275 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7276 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007277 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007278 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7279 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007280 case IntToPointer:
7281 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7282 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007283 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007284 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007285 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7286 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007287 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7288 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7289 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007290 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7291 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7292 break;
7293 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007294 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7295 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7296 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7297 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7298 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7299 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7300 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7301 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7302 // C++ semantics.
7303 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7304 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7305 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007306 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7307 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007308 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007309 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007310 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007311 case IntToBlockPointer:
7312 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7313 break;
7314 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007315 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007316 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007317 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007318 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007319 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7320 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7321 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007322 case IncompatibleVectors:
7323 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7324 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007325 case Incompatible:
7326 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7327 isInvalid = true;
7328 break;
7329 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007330
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007331 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7332 switch (Action) {
7333 case AA_Assigning:
7334 case AA_Initializing:
7335 // The destination type comes first.
7336 FirstType = DstType;
7337 SecondType = SrcType;
7338 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007339
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007340 case AA_Returning:
7341 case AA_Passing:
7342 case AA_Converting:
7343 case AA_Sending:
7344 case AA_Casting:
7345 // The source type comes first.
7346 FirstType = SrcType;
7347 SecondType = DstType;
7348 break;
7349 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007350
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007351 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007352 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007353 if (Complained)
7354 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007355 return isInvalid;
7356}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007357
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007358bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007359 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7360 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7361 if (Result)
7362 *Result = ICEResult;
7363 return false;
7364 }
7365
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007366 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7367
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007368 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007369 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7370 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7371
7372 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7373 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7374 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7375 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7376 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7377 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7378 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007379
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007380 return true;
7381 }
7382
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007383 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7384 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007385
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007386 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7387 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7388 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007389
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007390 if (Result)
7391 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7392 return false;
7393}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007394
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007395void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007396Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007397 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7398 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007399}
7400
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007401void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007402Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7403 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7404 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7405 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007406
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007407 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7408 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7409 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7410 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7411 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007412 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007413 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7414 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7415 I != IEnd; ++I)
7416 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7417 }
7418
7419 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7420 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7421 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7422 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7423 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7424 I != IEnd; ++I)
7425 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7426 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007427 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007428
7429 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7430 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7431 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7432 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007433 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007434 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7435 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7436 ExprTemporaries.end());
7437
7438 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7439 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007440}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007441
7442/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7443///
7444/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7445/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7446/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7447/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7448///
7449/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7450///
7451/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7452void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7453 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007454
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007455 if (D->isUsed())
7456 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007457
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007458 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7459 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7460 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7461 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007462 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007463 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007464 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007465 return;
7466 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007467
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007468 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7469 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007470
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007471 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7472 // an instantiation.
7473 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7474 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007475
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007476 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007477 case Unevaluated:
7478 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7479 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007480
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007481 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7482 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7483 // "used"; handle this below.
7484 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007485
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007486 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7487 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7488 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7489 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007490 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007491 return;
7492 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007493
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007494 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007495 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007496 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007497 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7498 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7499 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007500 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007501 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007502 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7503 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7504 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007505
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007506 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007507 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7508 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7509 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007510 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7511 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007512 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7513 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7514 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7515 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007516 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007517 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7518 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007519 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007520 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007521 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007522 // class templates.
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007523 if (!Function->getBody() && Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007524 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7525 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7526 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7527 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7528 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007529 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007530 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007531 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007532 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007533 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7534 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7535 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007536 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007537 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007538 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7539 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007540
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007541 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7542 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7543 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7544 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7545 Loc));
7546 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007547 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007548 Loc));
7549 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007550 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007551
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007552 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007553 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007554
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007555 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007556 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007557
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007558 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007559 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007560 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007561 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7562 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7563 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7564 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7565 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7566 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7567 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7568 }
7569 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007570
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007571 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007572
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007573 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007574 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007575 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007576}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007577
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007578namespace {
7579 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7580 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7581 // of when we're entering
7582 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7583 Sema &S;
7584 SourceLocation Loc;
7585
7586 public:
7587 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7588
7589 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7590
7591 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7592 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7593 };
7594}
7595
7596bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7597 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7598 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7599 }
7600
7601 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7602}
7603
7604bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7605 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7606 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7607 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7608 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7609 Args.flat_size());
7610 }
7611
7612 return false;
7613}
7614
7615void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7616 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7617 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7618}
7619
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007620/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7621/// of the program being compiled.
7622///
7623/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007624/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007625/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7626/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7627/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7628/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007629/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007630/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007631///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007632/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7633/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7634/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7635/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007636bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007637 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7638 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7639 case Unevaluated:
7640 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7641 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007642
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007643 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7644 Diag(Loc, PD);
7645 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007646
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007647 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7648 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7649 break;
7650 }
7651
7652 return false;
7653}
7654
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007655bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7656 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7657 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7658 return false;
7659
7660 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7661 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7662 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7663 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007664
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007665 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007666 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007667 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7668 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007669 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007670 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7671 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7672 return true;
7673
7674 return false;
7675}
7676
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007677// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7678// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7679void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7680 SourceLocation Loc;
7681
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007682 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7683
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007684 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7685 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7686 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7687 return;
7688
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007689 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7690 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7691 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7692 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7693
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007694 // self = [<foo> init...]
7695 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7696 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7697 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7698
7699 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7700 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7701 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7702 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7703 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007704
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007705 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7706 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7707 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7708 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7709 return;
7710
7711 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7712 } else {
7713 // Not an assignment.
7714 return;
7715 }
7716
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007717 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007718 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007719
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007720 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007721 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007722 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007723 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7724 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7725 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007726}
7727
7728bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7729 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7730
7731 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007732 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007733
7734 QualType T = E->getType();
7735
7736 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7737 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7738 return true;
7739 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7740 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7741 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7742 return true;
7743 }
7744 }
7745
7746 return false;
7747}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007748
7749Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7750 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007751 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7752 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007753 return ExprError();
7754
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007755 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7756 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7757 return ExprError();
7758 }
7759
7760 return Owned(Sub);
7761}